blob: 5e7a733e0fdf93f5620ce537fea5461f4b30ea80 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall5cebab12009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner07d754a2008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregorb53edfb2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
62 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
63 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() &&
168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000381
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
462
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000463/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000465Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000466 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
468 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000470 << D->getDeclName();
471 return ExprError();
472 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000473
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000474 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000475 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
476 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
477 // visible.
478 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000479 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
480 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000481 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000482 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000484 << D->getIdentifier();
485 return ExprError();
486 }
487 }
488 }
489 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000491 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000493 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
494 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
495 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregored6c7442009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000496 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000497}
498
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000499/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
500/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
501/// actual member.
502///
503/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
504/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
505/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
506/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
507/// we found.
508///
509/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
510/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
511/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
512VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
513 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000514 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
515 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
516 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
517
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000518 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000519 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
520 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
521 do {
522 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000523 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000524 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000525 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000526 else {
527 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
528 break;
529 }
530 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000531 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000532 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000533
534 return BaseObject;
535}
536
537Sema::OwningExprResult
538Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
539 FieldDecl *Field,
540 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
541 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
542 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000543 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000544 AnonFields);
545
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000546 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
547 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
548 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
549 // found via name lookup.
550 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000551 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000552 if (BaseObject) {
553 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
554 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000555 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000556 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000557 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000558 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000559 BaseQuals
560 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
562 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
563 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
564 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
565 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000566 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000567 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
568 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
569 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 BaseQuals
571 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000572 } else {
573 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
574 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
575 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000576 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
577 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000578 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000579 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 = Context.getTagDeclType(
581 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
582 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000583 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
585 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
586 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000587 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000588 MD->getThisType(Context),
589 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
591 }
592 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000593 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
594 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000596 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000597 }
598
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000599 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000600 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
601 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 }
603
604 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
605 // anonymous struct/union.
606 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
609 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
610 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
611 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000612 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
613 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
614
615 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
616 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
617 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
618 ResultQuals.removeConst();
619
620 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
621 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
622
623 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
624 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
625
626 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
627 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
628 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
629
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000630 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000631 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000632 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000633 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
634 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000635 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000636 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000637 }
638
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000639 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000640}
641
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000642/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
643/// possibly a list of template arguments.
644///
645/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
646/// DecomposeTemplateName.
647///
648/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
649/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
650/// some way.
651static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
652 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
653 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
654 DeclarationName &Name,
655 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
656 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
657 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
658 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
659 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
660
661 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
662 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
663 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
664 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
665 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
666
667 TemplateName TName =
668 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
669
670 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
671 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
672 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
673 } else {
674 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
675 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
676 TemplateArgs = 0;
677 }
678}
679
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000680/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
681/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
682/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000683static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000684 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
685 return false;
686
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000687 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
688 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
689 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
690 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
691 if (!BaseRT) return false;
692
693 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000694 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000695 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
696 return false;
697 }
698
699 return true;
700}
701
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000702/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
703/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
704static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000705 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000706
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000707 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
708 if (!DC) return true;
709
710 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
711 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
712
713 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
714 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
715
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000716 return false;
717}
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000718
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000719/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
720/// the prospective base classes.
721static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
722 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
723 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000724 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000725 return false;
726
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000727 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000728 if (!RD) return false;
729 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
730
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000731 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
732 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
733 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
734 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
735 if (!BaseRT) return false;
736
737 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000738 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
739 return false;
740 }
741
742 return true;
743}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000744
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000745enum IMAKind {
746 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
747 IMA_Static,
748
749 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
750 IMA_Mixed,
751
752 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
753 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
754 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
755
756 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
757 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
758 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
759
760 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
761 IMA_Instance,
762
763 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
764 IMA_Unresolved,
765
766 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
767 /// context is not an instance method.
768 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
769
770 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
771 /// non-class context.
772 IMA_AnonymousMember,
773
774 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
775 /// context is not an instance method.
776 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
777
778 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
779 /// class.
780 IMA_Error_Unrelated
781};
782
783/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
784/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
785/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
786/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
787/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
788/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
789static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
790 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000791 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000792
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000793 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000794 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000795 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
796 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000797
798 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
799 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
800
801 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
802 bool hasNonInstance = false;
803 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
804 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000805 NamedDecl *D = *I;
806 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000807 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
808
809 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
810 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
811 // that's a special case.
812 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
813 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
814 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
815 }
816 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
817 }
818 else
819 hasNonInstance = true;
820 }
821
822 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
823 // member reference.
824 if (Classes.empty())
825 return IMA_Static;
826
827 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
828 // an implicit member reference.
829 if (isStaticContext)
830 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
831
832 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
833 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
834 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
835 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000836 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000837 Classes))
838 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
839
840 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
841}
842
843/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
844static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
845 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
846 const LookupResult &R) {
847 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
848 SourceRange Range(Loc);
849 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
850
851 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
852 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
853 if (MD->isStatic()) {
854 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
855 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
856 << Range << R.getLookupName();
857 return;
858 }
859 }
860
861 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
862 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
863 return;
864 }
865
866 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000867}
868
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000869/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
870///
871/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000872bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +0000873 LookupResult &R, CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000874 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
875
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000876 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000877 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000878 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
879 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000880 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000881 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000882 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
883 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000884
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000885 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
886 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
887 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
888 // dependent name.
889 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty()? CurContext : 0;
890 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000891 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
892 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
893
894 if (!R.empty()) {
895 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
896 R.suppressDiagnostics();
897
898 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
899 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
900 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
901 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
902
903 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
904 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
905 // Actually quite difficult!
906 if (isInstance)
907 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000908 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000909 else
910 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
911
912 // Do we really want to note all of these?
913 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
914 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
915
916 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
917 return false;
918 }
919 }
920 }
921
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000922 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000923 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000924 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000925 if (!R.empty()) {
926 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
927 if (SS.isEmpty())
928 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
929 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
930 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
931 else
932 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
933 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
934 << SS.getRange()
935 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
936 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
937 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
938 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
939 << ND->getDeclName();
940
941 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
942 return false;
943 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000944
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000945 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
946 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
947 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
948 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
949 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
950 // to recover well anyway.
951 if (SS.isEmpty())
952 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
953 else
954 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
955 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
956 << SS.getRange();
957
958 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
959 return true;
960 }
961 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000962 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000963 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000964 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000965 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000966 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000967 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000968 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
969 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000970 return true;
971 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000972 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000973 }
974
975 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
976 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
977 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
978 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
979 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
980 << SS.getRange();
981 return true;
982 }
983
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000984 // Give up, we can't recover.
985 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
986 return true;
987}
988
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000989Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000990 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000991 UnqualifiedId &Id,
992 bool HasTrailingLParen,
993 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
994 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
995 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
996
997 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +0000998 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +0000999
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001000 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001001
1002 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1003 DeclarationName Name;
1004 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1005 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001006 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1007 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001008
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001009 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001010
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001011 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1012 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001013 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1014 // (note: handled after lookup)
1015 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1016 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1017 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001018 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1019 // names a dependent type.
1020 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1021 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001022 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1023 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1024 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001025 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001026 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001027 TemplateArgs);
1028 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001029
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001030 // Perform the required lookup.
1031 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1032 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001033 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1034 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1035 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1036 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1037 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001038 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1039 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1040 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001041 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001042 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1043 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001044
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001045 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1046 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001047 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1048 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001049 if (E.isInvalid())
1050 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001051
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001052 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1053 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001054 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001055 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001056
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001057 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1058 return ExprError();
1059
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001060 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1061 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001062 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001063
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001064 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001065 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001066 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1067 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1068 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1069 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1070 }
1071
1072 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1073 // call, diagnose the problem.
1074 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001075 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001076 return ExprError();
1077
1078 assert(!R.empty() &&
1079 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001080
1081 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1082 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001083 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001084 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1085 R.clear();
1086 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1087 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1088 return move(E);
1089 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001090 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001091 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001092
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001093 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1094 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1095
1096 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001097 // Warn about constructs like:
1098 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1099 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001100 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1101 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001102 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001103 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001104 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001105 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001106 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001107 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1108 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001109 break;
1110 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001111
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001112 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1113 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001114 }
1115 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001116 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001117 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1118 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1119 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1120 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1121 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1122 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001123 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001124 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001125
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001126 QualType T = Func->getType();
1127 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001128 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001129 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1130 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001131 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001132 }
1133 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001134
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001135 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1136 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1137 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1138 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1139 // class member access expression.
1140 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1141 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001142 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001143 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001144 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1145 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001146 }
1147
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001148 if (TemplateArgs)
1149 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001150
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001151 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1152}
1153
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001154/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1155Sema::OwningExprResult
1156Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1157 LookupResult &R,
1158 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1159 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1160 case IMA_Instance:
1161 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1162
1163 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1164 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1165 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1166 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1167
1168 case IMA_Mixed:
1169 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1170 case IMA_Unresolved:
1171 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1172
1173 case IMA_Static:
1174 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1175 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1176 if (TemplateArgs)
1177 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1178 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1179
1180 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1181 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1182 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1183 return ExprError();
1184 }
1185
1186 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1187 return ExprError();
1188}
1189
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001190/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1191/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1192/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1193/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001194Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001195Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001196 DeclarationName Name,
1197 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1198 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001199 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001200 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1201
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001202 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001203 return ExprError();
1204
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001205 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1206 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1207
1208 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1209 return ExprError();
1210
1211 if (R.empty()) {
1212 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1213 return ExprError();
1214 }
1215
1216 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1217}
1218
1219/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1220/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1221/// additional lookup.
1222///
1223/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1224/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1225///
1226/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1227Sema::OwningExprResult
1228Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001229 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001230 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001231 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001232
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001233 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1234 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1235 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1236 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1237 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1238
1239 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1240 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1241 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001242 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001243
1244 bool LookForIvars;
1245 if (Lookup.empty())
1246 LookForIvars = true;
1247 else if (IsClassMethod)
1248 LookForIvars = false;
1249 else
1250 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1251 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001252 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001253 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001254 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001255 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1256 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1257 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1258 if (IsClassMethod)
1259 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1260 << IV->getDeclName());
1261
1262 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1263 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1264 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1265 return ExprError();
1266
1267 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1268 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1269 return ExprError();
1270
1271 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1272 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1273 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1274 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1275
1276 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1277 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1278 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1279 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001280 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001281 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1282 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1283 SelfName, false, false);
1284 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1285 return Owned(new (Context)
1286 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1287 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1288 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001289 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001290 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001291 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001292 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1293 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1294 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1295 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1296 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1297 }
1298 }
1299
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001300 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1301 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1302 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1303 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1304 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1305 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1306 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1307 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1308 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1309 }
1310 }
1311 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001312 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1313 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001314}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001315
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001316/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1317///
1318/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1319///
1320/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1321/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1322/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1323/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1324///
1325/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1326/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1327/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1328/// the class declaring the member.
1329///
1330/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1331/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1332/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001333bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001334Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1335 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001336 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001337 NamedDecl *Member) {
1338 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1339 if (!RD)
1340 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001341
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001342 QualType DestRecordType;
1343 QualType DestType;
1344 QualType FromRecordType;
1345 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1346 bool PointerConversions = false;
1347 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1348 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001349
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001350 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1351 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1352 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1353 PointerConversions = true;
1354 } else {
1355 DestType = DestRecordType;
1356 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001357 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001358 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1359 if (Method->isStatic())
1360 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001361
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001362 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1363 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001364
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001365 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1366 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1367 PointerConversions = true;
1368 } else {
1369 FromRecordType = FromType;
1370 DestType = DestRecordType;
1371 }
1372 } else {
1373 // No conversion necessary.
1374 return false;
1375 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001376
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001377 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1378 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001379
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001380 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1381 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1382 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001383
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001384 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1385 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1386
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001387 bool isLvalue
1388 = (From->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) && !PointerConversions;
1389
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001390 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001391 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001392 // class name.
1393 //
1394 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1395 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1396 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1397 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1398 //
1399 // class Base { public: int x; };
1400 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1401 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1402 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1403 //
1404 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1405 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1406 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1407 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001408 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001409 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1410 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1411 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1412
1413 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1414
1415 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1416 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1417 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1418 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001419 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001420 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001421 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001422 return true;
1423
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001424 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001425 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001426 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001427 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001428
1429 FromType = QType;
1430 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1431
1432 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1433 // we're done.
1434 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1435 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001436 }
1437 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001438
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001439 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001440
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001441 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1442 // down to the using declaration's type.
1443 //
1444 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1445 // class ever has member declarations.
1446 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1447 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1448 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1449 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1450
1451 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1452 // conversion is non-trivial.
1453 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1454 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001455 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001456 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001457 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001458 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001459
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001460 QualType UType = URecordType;
1461 if (PointerConversions)
1462 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001463 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001464 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001465 FromType = UType;
1466 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1467 }
1468
1469 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1470 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1471 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001472 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001473
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001474 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1475 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1476 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001477 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001478 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001479
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001480 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001481 isLvalue, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001482 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001483}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001484
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001485/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001486static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001487 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001488 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1489 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001490 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1491 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1492 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001493 if (SS.isSet()) {
1494 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1495 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001496 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001497
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001498 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001499 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001500}
1501
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001502/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1503/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1504/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1505/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001506Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001507Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1508 LookupResult &R,
1509 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1510 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001511 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1512
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001513 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001514
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001515 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1516 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001517 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001518 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001519 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001520 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001521 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001522
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001523 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1524 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001525 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1526 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001527 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1528 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001529 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1530 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1531 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1532 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001533 }
1534
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001535 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1536 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1537 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001538 SS,
1539 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1540 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001541}
1542
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001543bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001544 const LookupResult &R,
1545 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001546 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1547 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1548 return false;
1549
1550 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001551 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001552 return false;
1553
1554 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001555 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001556 return false;
1557
1558 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1559 // normal lookup:
1560 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1561 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1562
1563 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1564 // -- a declaration of a class member
1565 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1566 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001567 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001568 return false;
1569
1570 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1571 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1572 // using-declaration
1573 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1574 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1575 // turn off ADL anyway).
1576 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1577 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1578 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1579 return false;
1580
1581 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1582 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1583 // template
1584 // And also for builtin functions.
1585 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1586 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1587
1588 // But also builtin functions.
1589 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1590 return false;
1591 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1592 return false;
1593 }
1594
1595 return true;
1596}
1597
1598
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001599/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1600/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1601/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1602/// will in fact be used.
1603static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1604 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1605 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1606 return true;
1607 }
1608
1609 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1610 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1611 return true;
1612 }
1613
1614 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1615 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1616 return true;
1617 }
1618
1619 return false;
1620}
1621
1622Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001623Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001624 LookupResult &R,
1625 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001626 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1627 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001628 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001629 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001630
1631 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1632 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1633 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001634 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1635 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001636 return ExprError();
1637
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001638 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1639 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1640 // we've picked a target.
1641 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1642
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001643 bool Dependent
1644 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001645 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001646 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001647 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1648 SS.getRange(),
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001649 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001650 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1651 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001652
1653 return Owned(ULE);
1654}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001655
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001656
1657/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1658Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001659Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001660 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1661 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001662 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1663 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001664
1665 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1666 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001667
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001668 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1669 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1670 // a template argument list.
1671 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1672 << Template << SS.getRange();
1673 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1674 return ExprError();
1675 }
1676
1677 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1678 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1679 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001680 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001681 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001682 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001683 return ExprError();
1684 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001685
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001686 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1687 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1688 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1689 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001690 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001691 return ExprError();
1692
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001693 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1694 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001695 return ExprError();
1696
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001697 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1698 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1699 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1700 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001701 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001702 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1703 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1704 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001705 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001706 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001707 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1708 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1709 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1710 return ExprError();
1711 }
1712
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001713 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001714 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1715 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1716 return ExprError();
1717 }
1718
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001719 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001720 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001721 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001722 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001723 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001724 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1725 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001726 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001727
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001728 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001729 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1730 ExprTy, Loc, false,
1731 constAdded);
1732 QualType T = VD->getType();
1733 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !T->isDependentType() &&
1734 !T->isReferenceType()) {
1735 Expr *E = new (Context)
1736 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1737 SourceLocation());
1738
1739 OwningExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001740 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
1741 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001742 SourceLocation(),
1743 Owned(E));
1744 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001745 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(move(Res));
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001746 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanian8e739282010-06-08 17:52:11 +00001747 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001748 }
1749 }
1750 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001751 }
1752 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1753 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001754
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001755 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001756}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001757
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001758Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1759 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001760 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001761
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001762 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001763 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001764 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1765 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1766 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001767 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001768
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001769 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1770 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001771
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001772 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1773 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001774 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001775 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001776 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001777
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001778 QualType ResTy;
1779 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1780 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1781 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001782 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001783
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001784 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001785 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001786 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1787 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001788 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001789}
1790
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001791Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001792 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001793 bool Invalid = false;
1794 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1795 if (Invalid)
1796 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001797
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001798 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1799 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001800 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001801 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001802
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001803 QualType Ty;
1804 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1805 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1806 else if (Literal.isWide())
1807 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001808 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1809 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001810 else
1811 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001812
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001813 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1814 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001815 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001816}
1817
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001818Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1819 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001820 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1821 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001822 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001823 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001824 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001825 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001826 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001827
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001828 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001829 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1830 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001831 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001832
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001833 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001834 bool Invalid = false;
1835 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1836 if (Invalid)
1837 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001838
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001839 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001840 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001841 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001842 return ExprError();
1843
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001844 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001845
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001846 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001847 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001848 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001849 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001850 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001851 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001852 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001853 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001854
1855 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1856
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001857 using llvm::APFloat;
1858 APFloat Val(Format);
1859
1860 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001861
1862 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1863 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1864 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1865 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001866 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001867 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001868 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001869 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001870 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1871 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001872 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001873 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1874 }
1875
1876 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1877 << Ty
1878 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1879 }
1880
1881 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001882 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001883
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001884 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001885 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001886 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001887 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001888
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001889 // long long is a C99 feature.
1890 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001891 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001892 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1893
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001894 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001895 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001896
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001897 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1898 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1899 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001900 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1901 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001902 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001903 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001904 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1905 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001906
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001907 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1908 // be an unsigned int.
1909 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1910
1911 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001912 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001913 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1914 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001915 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001916
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001917 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1918 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1919 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1920 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001921 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001922 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001923 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001924 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001925 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001926 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001927
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001928 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001929 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001930 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001931
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001932 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1933 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1934 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1935 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001936 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001937 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001938 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001939 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001940 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001941 }
1942
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001943 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001944 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001945 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001946
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001947 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1948 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1949 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1950 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001951 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001952 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001953 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001954 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001955 }
1956 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001957
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001958 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1959 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001960 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001961 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001962 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001963 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001964 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001965
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001966 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1967 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001968 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001969 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001970 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001971
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001972 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1973 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001974 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001975 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001976
1977 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001978}
1979
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001980Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
1981 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00001982 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001983 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001984 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001985}
1986
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00001987/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00001988/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00001989bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00001990 SourceLocation OpLoc,
1991 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
1992 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00001993 if (exprType->isDependentType())
1994 return false;
1995
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001996 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
1997 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
1998 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
1999 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2000 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2001 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2002
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002003 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002004 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002005 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002006 if (isSizeof)
2007 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2008 return false;
2009 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002010
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002011 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002012 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002013 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2014 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002015 return false;
2016 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002017
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002018 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002019 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2020 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002021 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002022
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002023 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002024 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002025 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002026 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2027 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002028 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002029
Douglas Gregor27887822010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002030 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2031 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2032 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2033 return true;
2034 }
2035
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002036 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002037}
2038
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002039bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2040 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2041 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002042
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002043 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002044 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2045 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002046
2047 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2048 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2049 return false;
2050
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002051 if (E->getBitField()) {
2052 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2053 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002054 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002055
2056 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2057 // bit-field.
2058 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002059 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002060 return false;
2061
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002062 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2063}
2064
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002065/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002066Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002067Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002068 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002069 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002070 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002071 return ExprError();
2072
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002073 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002074
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002075 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2076 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2077 return ExprError();
2078
2079 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002080 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002081 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2082 R.getEnd()));
2083}
2084
2085/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2086/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002087Action::OwningExprResult
2088Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002089 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2090 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2091 bool isInvalid = false;
2092 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2093 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2094 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2095 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002096 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002097 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2098 isInvalid = true;
2099 } else {
2100 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2101 }
2102
2103 if (isInvalid)
2104 return ExprError();
2105
2106 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2107 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2108 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2109 R.getEnd()));
2110}
2111
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002112/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2113/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2114/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002115Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002116Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2117 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002118 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002119 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002120
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002121 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002122 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2123 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2124 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002125 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002126
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002127 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2128 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2129 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2130
2131 if (Result.isInvalid())
2132 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2133
2134 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002135}
2136
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002137QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002138 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2139 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002140
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002141 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002142 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002143 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002144
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002145 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2146 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2147 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002148
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002149 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002150 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2151 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002152 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002153}
2154
2155
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002156
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002157Action::OwningExprResult
2158Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2159 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002160 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2161 switch (Kind) {
2162 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2163 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2164 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2165 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002166
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002167 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002168}
2169
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002170Action::OwningExprResult
2171Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2172 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002173 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2174 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2175
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002176 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2177 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002178
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002179 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002180 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2181 Base.release();
2182 Idx.release();
2183 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2184 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2185 }
2186
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002187 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002188 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002189 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2190 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2191 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002192 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002193 }
2194
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002195 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2196}
2197
2198
2199Action::OwningExprResult
2200Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2201 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2202 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2203 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2204
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002205 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002206 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2207 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2208 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002209
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002210 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002211
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002212 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002213 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002214 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002215 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002216 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2217 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002218 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2219 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2220 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2221 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002222 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002223 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2224 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002225 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002226 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002227 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002228 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2229 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002230 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002231 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002232 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002233 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2234 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2235 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002236 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002237 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002238 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2239 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2240 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2241 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002242 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002243 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002244 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002245
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002246 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2247 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002248 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2249 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002250 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002251 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2252 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2253 // force the promotion here.
2254 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2255 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002256 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2257 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002258 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2259
2260 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2261 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002262 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002263 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2264 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2265 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2266 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002267 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2268 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002269 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2270
2271 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2272 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002273 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002274 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002275 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2276 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002277 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002278 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002279 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2280 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002281 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2282 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002283
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002284 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002285 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2286 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002287 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2288
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002289 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002290 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2291 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002292 // incomplete types are not object types.
2293 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2294 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2295 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2296 return ExprError();
2297 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002298
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002299 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002300 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002301 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2302 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002303 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002304
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002305 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002306 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002307 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2308 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2309 return ExprError();
2310 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002311
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002312 Base.release();
2313 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002314 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002315 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002316}
2317
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002318QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002319CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002320 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002321 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002322 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2323 // see FIXME there.
2324 //
2325 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2326 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002327 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002328
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002329 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002330 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002331
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002332 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002333 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2334 // to be selected.
2335 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002336
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002337 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2338 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002339 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002340
2341 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2342 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002343 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002344 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2345 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002346 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002347 do
2348 compStr++;
2349 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002350 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002351 do
2352 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002353 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002354 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002355
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002356 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002357 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2358 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002359 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2360 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002361 return QualType();
2362 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002363
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002364 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2365 // operates on.
2366 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002367 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002368
2369 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002370 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002371
2372 while (*compStr) {
2373 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2374 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2375 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2376 return QualType();
2377 }
2378 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002379 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002380
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002381 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002382 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002383 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002384 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002385 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002386 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002387 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002388 if (HexSwizzle)
2389 CompSize--;
2390
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002391 if (CompSize == 1)
2392 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002393
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002394 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002395 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002396 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2397 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2398 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2399 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002400 }
2401 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002402}
2403
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002404static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002405 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002406 const Selector &Sel,
2407 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002408
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002409 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002410 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002411 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002412 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002413
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002414 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2415 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002416 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002417 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002418 return D;
2419 }
2420 return 0;
2421}
2422
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002423static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002424 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002425 const Selector &Sel,
2426 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002427 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2428 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002429 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002430 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002431 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002432 GDecl = PD;
2433 break;
2434 }
2435 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002436 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002437 GDecl = OMD;
2438 break;
2439 }
2440 }
2441 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002442 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002443 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2444 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002445 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002446 if (GDecl)
2447 return GDecl;
2448 }
2449 }
2450 return GDecl;
2451}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002452
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002453Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002454Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2455 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002456 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2457 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2458 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2459 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2460 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2461
2462 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2463 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2464 //
2465 // T* t;
2466 // t.f;
2467 //
2468 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2469 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2470 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2471 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002472 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002473 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2474 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002475 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002476 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002477 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002478 return ExprError();
2479 }
2480 }
2481
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002482 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002483 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002484
2485 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2486 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002487 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002488 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2489 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2490 SS.getRange(),
2491 FirstQualifierInScope,
2492 Name, NameLoc,
2493 TemplateArgs));
2494}
2495
2496/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2497/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2498/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2499static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2500 Expr *BaseExpr,
2501 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002502 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002503 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002504 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2505 // diagnostics.
2506 if (!BaseExpr)
2507 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002508
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002509 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2510 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002511}
2512
2513// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2514// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2515// type. The restriction here is:
2516//
2517// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2518// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2519// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2520//
2521// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2522// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2523// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2524// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2525bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2526 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002527 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002528 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002529 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2530 if (!BaseRT) {
2531 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2532 // dependent.
2533 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2534 return false;
2535 }
2536 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002537
2538 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002539 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2540 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002541 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002542 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002543
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002544 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2545 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2546 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2547 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2548
2549 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2550 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2551
2552 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2553 return false;
2554 }
2555
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002556 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002557 return true;
2558}
2559
2560static bool
2561LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2562 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002563 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2564 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002565 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2566 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002567 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002568 << BaseRange))
2569 return true;
2570
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002571 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2572 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2573 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2574
2575 bool MOUS;
2576 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2577 return false;
2578 }
2579
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002580 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2581 if (SS.isSet()) {
2582 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2583 // nested-name-specifier.
2584 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2585
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002586 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002587 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2588 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2589 return true;
2590 }
2591
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002592 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002593
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002594 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2595 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2596 << DC << SS.getRange();
2597 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002598 }
2599 }
2600
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002601 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2602 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002603
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002604 if (!R.empty())
2605 return false;
2606
2607 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2608 // for typos.
2609 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002610 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002611 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002612 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2613 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2614 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002615 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2616 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002617 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2618 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2619 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002620 return false;
2621 } else {
2622 R.clear();
2623 }
2624
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002625 return false;
2626}
2627
2628Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002629Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002630 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002631 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002632 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2633 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2634 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2635 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2636
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002637 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2638 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002639 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002640 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2641 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2642 Name, NameLoc,
2643 TemplateArgs);
2644
2645 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002646
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002647 // Implicit member accesses.
2648 if (!Base) {
2649 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2650 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2651 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2652 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002653 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002654 return ExprError();
2655
2656 // Explicit member accesses.
2657 } else {
2658 OwningExprResult Result =
2659 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002660 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy(), TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002661
2662 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2663 Owned(Base);
2664 return ExprError();
2665 }
2666
2667 if (Result.get())
2668 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002669
2670 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2671 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002672 }
2673
Sebastian Redl0b4e3122010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002674 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002675 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2676 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002677}
2678
2679Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002680Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2681 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2682 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002683 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002684 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002685 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2686 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002687 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002688 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002689 if (IsArrow) {
2690 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2691 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2692 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002693 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002694
2695 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2696 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2697 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2698 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2699
2700 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002701 return ExprError();
2702
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002703 if (R.empty()) {
2704 // Rederive where we looked up.
2705 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2706 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2707 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002708
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002709 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002710 << MemberName << DC
2711 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002712 return ExprError();
2713 }
2714
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002715 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2716 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2717 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2718 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2719 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2720 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2721 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2722 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2723 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2724 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002725 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002726 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002727 return ExprError();
2728
2729 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2730 // result.
2731 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002732 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002733 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002734 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002735 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002736
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002737 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2738 // pick a member.
2739 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2740
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002741 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2742 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2743 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002744 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2745 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002746 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2747 MemberName, MemberLoc,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002748 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002749
2750 return Owned(MemExpr);
2751 }
2752
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002753 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002754 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002755 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2756
2757 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2758
2759 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2760 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2761 // error cases.
2762 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2763 return ExprError();
2764
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002765 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2766 if (!BaseExpr) {
2767 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002768 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002769 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2770
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002771 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2772 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2773 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2774 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002775 }
2776
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002777 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2778 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2779 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2780 // explicitly qualified.
2781 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2782 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2783 }
2784
2785 // Check the use of this member.
2786 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2787 Owned(BaseExpr);
2788 return ExprError();
2789 }
2790
2791 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2792 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2793 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002794 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2795 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002796 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2797 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2798
2799 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2800 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2801 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2802 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2803 else {
2804 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2805 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2806 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2807
2808 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2809 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2810
2811 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2812 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2813 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2814 }
2815
2816 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002817 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002818 return ExprError();
2819 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002820 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002821 }
2822
2823 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2824 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2825 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002826 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002827 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2828 }
2829
2830 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2831 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2832 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002833 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002834 MemberFn->getType()));
2835 }
2836
2837 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2838 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2839 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002840 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002841 }
2842
2843 Owned(BaseExpr);
2844
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002845 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002846 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002847 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2848 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2849 else
2850 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2851 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002852
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002853 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2854 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002855 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002856 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002857}
2858
2859/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2860/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2861/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2862/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2863/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2864/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2865/// an ordinary member expression.
2866///
2867/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2868/// fixed for ObjC++.
2869Sema::OwningExprResult
2870Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002871 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002872 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002873 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002874 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002875
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002876 // Perform default conversions.
2877 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002878
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002879 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002880 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2881
2882 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2883 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002884
2885 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002886 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002887 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2888 // call, and continue on.
2889 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2890 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2891 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2892 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2893 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002894 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2895 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002896 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2897 ->isRecordType()))) {
2898 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2899 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2900 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002901 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002902
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002903 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002904 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002905 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00002906 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002907 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002908 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002909
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002910 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2911 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2912 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2913 }
2914 }
2915 }
2916
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002917 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2918 // use that.
2919 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002920 if (IsArrow) {
2921 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2922 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2923 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002924 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002925 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002926 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2927 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002928 }
2929 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002930 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2931 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2932 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2933 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002934 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002935 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002936 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002937
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002938 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2939 // use that.
2940 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2941 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2942 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2943 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2944 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2945 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2946 }
2947 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002948
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002949 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002950
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002951 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002952 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002953 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2954 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2955 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2956 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2957 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2958 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2959 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2960 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2961 // Check the use of this method.
2962 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2963 return ExprError();
2964 }
2965 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2966 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2967 Selector SetterSel =
2968 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2969 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2970 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2971 if (!Setter) {
2972 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2973 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002974 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002975 }
2976 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2977 if (!Setter)
2978 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002979
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002980 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
2981 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002982
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002983 if (Getter || Setter) {
2984 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002985
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002986 if (Getter)
2987 PType = Getter->getResultType();
2988 else
2989 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
2990 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
2991 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002992 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002993 PType,
2994 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
2995 }
2996 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
2997 << MemberName << BaseType);
2998 }
2999 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003000
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003001 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3002 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3003 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003004 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003005 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003006
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003007 if (IsArrow) {
3008 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003009 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003010 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3011 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003012 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3013 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3014 // struct MyRecord foo;
3015 // foo->bar
3016 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3017 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3018 // by now.
3019 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3020 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003021 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003022 IsArrow = false;
3023 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003024 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3025 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3026 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003027 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003028 } else {
3029 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3030 // type *foo;
3031 // foo.bar
3032 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3033 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3034 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3035 // the appropriate pointer type
3036 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3037 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3038 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3039 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3040 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003041 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003042 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3043 IsArrow = true;
3044 }
3045 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003046 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003047
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003048 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003049 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003050 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003051 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003052 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003053 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003054 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003055
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003056 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3057 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003058 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003059 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003060 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003061 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3062 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3063 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3064 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003065 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3066
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003067 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003068 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003069
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003070 if (!IV) {
3071 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3072 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3073 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003074 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003075 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003076 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003077 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3078 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003079 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3080 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003081 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003082 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003083 }
3084 }
3085
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003086 if (IV) {
3087 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3088 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3089 // error cases.
3090 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3091 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003092
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003093 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3094 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3095 return ExprError();
3096 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3097 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3098 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3099 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3100 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3101 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3102 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3103 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3104 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3105 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3106 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3107 // AST for a function decl.
3108 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003109 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003110 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3111 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3112 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3113 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3114 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3115 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003116
3117 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3118 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003119 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003120 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003121 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003122 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3123 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003124 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003125 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003126 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003127
3128 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3129 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003130 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003131 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003132 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003133 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003134 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003135 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003136 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003137 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003138 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3139 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003140 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003141 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003142
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003143 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003144 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003145 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3146 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3147 // Check the use of this declaration
3148 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3149 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003150
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003151 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3152 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3153 }
3154 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3155 // Check the use of this method.
3156 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3157 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003158
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003159 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003160 OMD->getResultType().getNonReferenceType(),
3161 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3162 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003163 }
3164 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003165
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003166 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003167 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003168 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003169
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003170 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3171 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003172 if (!IsArrow)
3173 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3174 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003175 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003176
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003177 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003178 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003179 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3180 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003181 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003182 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003183 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003184
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003185 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003186 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003187 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003188 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3189 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003190 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003191 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003192 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003193 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003194
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003195 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3196 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3197
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003198 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003199}
3200
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003201/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3202/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3203/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3204/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3205/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3206///
3207/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3208/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3209/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3210/// only be called
3211/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3212/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3213/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3214Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3215 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3216 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003217 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003218 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3219 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3220 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3221 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3222 return ExprError();
3223
3224 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3225
3226 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3227 DeclarationName Name;
3228 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3229 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3230 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3231 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3232
3233 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3234
3235 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3236 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3237 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3238
3239 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3240 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3241
3242 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3243 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003244 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3245 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003246 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003247 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3248 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3249 Name, NameLoc,
3250 TemplateArgs);
3251 } else {
3252 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003253 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3254 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003255
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003256 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3257 Owned(Base);
3258 return ExprError();
3259 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003260
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003261 if (Result.get()) {
3262 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3263 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3264 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3265 // call now.
3266 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3267 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
3268 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003269
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003270 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003271 }
3272
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003273 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003274 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3275 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003276 }
3277
3278 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003279}
3280
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003281Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3282 FunctionDecl *FD,
3283 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3284 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3285 Diag (CallLoc,
3286 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3287 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003288 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003289 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3290 } else {
3291 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3292 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3293
3294 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003295 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3296 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003297
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003298 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3299 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregor01afeef2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003300 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003301
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003302 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003303 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003304 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003305
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003306 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3307 InitializedEntity Entity
3308 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3309 InitializationKind Kind
3310 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3311 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3312 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3313
3314 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003315 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003316 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3317 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003318 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003319
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003320 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003321 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003322 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003323 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003324
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003325 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3326 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3327 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003328 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3329 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003330 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3331 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003332 }
3333
3334 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003335 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003336}
3337
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003338/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3339/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3340/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3341/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3342/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3343/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003344bool
3345Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003346 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003347 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003348 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3349 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003350 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003351 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3352 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003353 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003354
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003355 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3356 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3357 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3358 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3359 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003360 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003361 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003362 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003363 }
3364
3365 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3366 // them.
3367 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3368 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3369 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3370 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003371 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003372 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003373 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3374 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3375 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003376 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003377 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003378 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003379 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003380 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003381 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003382 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3383 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3384 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3385 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3386 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003387 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003388 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003389 if (Invalid)
3390 return true;
3391 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3392 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3393 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003394
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003395 return false;
3396}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003397
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003398bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3399 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3400 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3401 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3402 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3403 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003404 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003405 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3406 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3407 bool Invalid = false;
3408 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3409 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3410 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3411 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003412 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003413 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003414 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003415
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003416 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003417 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3418 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003419
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003420 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3421 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003422 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003423 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003424 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003425
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003426 // Pass the argument
3427 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3428 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3429 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003430
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003431
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003432 InitializedEntity Entity =
3433 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3434 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3435 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3436 SourceLocation(),
3437 Owned(Arg));
3438 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3439 return true;
3440
3441 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003442 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003443 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003444
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003445 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003446 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003447 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3448 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003449
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003450 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003451 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003452 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003453 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003454
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003455 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003456 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003457 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003458 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003459 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003460 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003461 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003462 }
3463 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003464 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003465}
3466
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003467/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003468/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3469/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003470Action::OwningExprResult
3471Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3472 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003473 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003474 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003475
3476 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3477 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003478
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003479 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003480 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003481 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003482
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003483 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003484 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3485 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3486 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3487 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3488 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003489 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003490 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3491 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003492
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003493 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3494 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003495
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003496 NumArgs = 0;
3497 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003498
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003499 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3500 RParenLoc));
3501 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003502
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003503 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003504 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003505 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3506 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003507 bool Dependent = false;
3508 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3509 Dependent = true;
3510 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3511 Dependent = true;
3512
3513 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003514 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003515 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3516
3517 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3518 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3519 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3520 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3521
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003522 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3523
3524 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3525 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3526 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3527 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3528 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3529 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3530 // method template.
3531 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003532 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3533 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003534 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003535
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003536 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3537 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003538 }
3539
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003540 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003541 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003542 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003543 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003544 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3545 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003546 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003547
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003548 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003549 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003550 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3551 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003552 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3553 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003554 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003555
3556 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3557 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003558 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3559 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003560
3561 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3562 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003563 TheCall.get(), 0))
3564 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003565
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003566 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003567 RParenLoc))
3568 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003569
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003570 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3571 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003572 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003573 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3574 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003575 }
3576 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003577 }
3578
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003579 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003580 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003581 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003582
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003583 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003584 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3585 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003586 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003587 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003588 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003589
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003590 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3591 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3592 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3593
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003594 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3595}
3596
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003597/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3598/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003599/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3600/// block-pointer type.
3601///
3602/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3603Sema::OwningExprResult
3604Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3605 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3606 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3607 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3608 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3609
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003610 // Promote the function operand.
3611 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3612
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003613 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3614 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003615 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3616 Args, NumArgs,
3617 Context.BoolTy,
3618 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003619
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003620 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3621 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3622 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3623 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003624 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003625 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003626 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3627 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003628 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003629 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003630 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003631 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003632 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003633 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003634 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3635 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3636
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003637 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003638 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003639 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3640 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003641 return ExprError();
3642
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003643 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003644 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003645
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003646 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003647 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003648 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003649 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003650 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003651 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003652
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003653 if (FDecl) {
3654 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3655 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3656 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisddcd1322009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003657 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003658 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003659 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003660 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3661 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3662 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3663 }
3664 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003665 }
3666
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003667 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003668 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3669 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3670 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003671 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3672 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003673 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3674 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003675 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003676 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003677 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003678 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003679
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003680 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3681 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003682 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3683 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003684
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003685 // Check for sentinels
3686 if (NDecl)
3687 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003688
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003689 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003690 if (FDecl) {
3691 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3692 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003693
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003694 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003695 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3696 } else if (NDecl) {
3697 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3698 return ExprError();
3699 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003700
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003701 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003702}
3703
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003704Action::OwningExprResult
3705Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3706 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003707 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003708 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003709 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003710
3711 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3712 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3713 if (!TInfo)
3714 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3715
3716 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3717}
3718
3719Action::OwningExprResult
3720Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3721 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3722 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003723 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003724
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003725 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003726 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003727 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3728 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003729 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3730 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003731 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003732 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003733 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003734 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003735
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003736 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003737 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003738 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003739 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003740 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003741 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3742 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3743 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3744 &literalType);
3745 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003746 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003747 InitExpr.release();
3748 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003749
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003750 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003751 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003752 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003753 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003754 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003755
3756 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003757
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003758 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003759 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003760}
3761
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003762Action::OwningExprResult
3763Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003764 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3765 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3766 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003767
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003768 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003769 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003770
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003771 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3772 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003773 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003774 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003775}
3776
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003777static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3778 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003779 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003780 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3781
3782 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3783 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003784 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3785 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003786 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003787 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3788 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3789 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003790
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003791 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3792 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3793 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3794 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3795 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3796 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3797 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3798 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003799
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003800 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3801 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3802 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3803 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3804 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3805 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003806
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003807 // FIXME: Assert here.
3808 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3809 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3810}
3811
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003812/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003813bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003814 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003815 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003816 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003817 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003818 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3819 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003820
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003821 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003822
3823 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3824 // type needs to be scalar.
3825 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3826 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003827 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3828 return false;
3829 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003830
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003831 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003832 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003833 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3834 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003835 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003836 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3837 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003838 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003839 return false;
3840 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003841
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003842 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003843 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003844 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003845 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003846 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003847 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003848 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003849 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003850 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3851 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3852 break;
3853 }
3854 }
3855 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3856 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3857 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003858 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003859 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003860 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003861
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003862 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3863 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3864 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3865 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003866
3867 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003868 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003869 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3870 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003871 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003872 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003873
3874 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003875 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003876
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003877 if (castType->isVectorType())
3878 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3879 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3880 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3881
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003882 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3883 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003884
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003885 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003886 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003887 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00003888 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003889 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3890 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3891 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3892 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003893 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003894 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3895 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3896 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003897 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003898
3899 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003900 return false;
3901}
3902
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003903bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3904 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003905 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003906
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003907 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003908 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003909 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003910 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003911 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003912 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003913 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003914 } else
3915 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003916 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003917 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003918
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003919 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003920 return false;
3921}
3922
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003923bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003924 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003925 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003926
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003927 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003928
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00003929 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
3930 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003931 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
3932 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3933 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
3934 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003935 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003936 return false;
3937 }
3938
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003939 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003940 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
3941 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003942 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
3943 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
3944 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
3945 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003946
3947 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
3948 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
3949 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003950
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003951 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003952 return false;
3953}
3954
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003955Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003956Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003957 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3958 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
3959 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00003960
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00003961 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
3962 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
3963 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003964 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003965
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003966 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003967 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003968 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003969 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
3970 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003971
3972 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
3973}
3974
3975Action::OwningExprResult
3976Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
3977 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3978 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
3979
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003980 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00003981 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003982 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003983 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003984 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00003985
Douglas Gregorb33eed02010-04-16 22:09:46 +00003986 Op.release();
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003987 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00003988 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssonf10e4142009-08-07 22:21:05 +00003989 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003990}
3991
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003992/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
3993/// of comma binary operators.
3994Action::OwningExprResult
3995Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
3996 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
3997 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
3998 if (!E)
3999 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004000
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004001 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004002
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004003 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4004 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4005 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004006
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004007 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4008}
4009
4010Action::OwningExprResult
4011Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4012 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004013 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004014 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004015 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004016
4017 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004018 // then handle it as such.
4019 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4020 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4021 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4022 return ExprError();
4023 }
4024
4025 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4026 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4027 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4028
4029 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4030 // braces instead of the original commas.
4031 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004032 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4033 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004034 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4035 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004036 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004037 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004038 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004039 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4040 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004041 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004042 }
4043}
4044
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004045Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004046 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004047 MultiExprArg Val,
4048 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004049 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4050 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004051 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4052 Expr *expr;
4053 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4054 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4055 else
4056 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004057 return Owned(expr);
4058}
4059
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004060/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4061/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004062/// C99 6.5.15
4063QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4064 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004065 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4066 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4067 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4068
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004069 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4070 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4071 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4072 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4073 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4074 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004075
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004076 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004077 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4078 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4079 << CondTy;
4080 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004081 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004082
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004083 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004084 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4085 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004086
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004087 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4088 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004089 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4090 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4091 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004092 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004093
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004094 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4095 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004096 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4097 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004098 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004099 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004100 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004101 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004102 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004103 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004104
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004105 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004106 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004107 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4108 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4109 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4110 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4111 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4112 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4113 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004114 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4115 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004116 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004117 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004118 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4119 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004120 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004121 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004122 // promote the null to a pointer.
4123 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004124 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004125 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004126 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004127 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004128 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004129 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004130 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004131
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004132 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4133 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4134 QuestionLoc);
4135 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4136 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004137
4138
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004139 // Handle block pointer types.
4140 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4141 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4142 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4143 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004144 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4145 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004146 return destType;
4147 }
4148 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004149 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004150 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004151 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004152 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4153 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4154 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004155 return LHSTy;
4156 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004157 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004158 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4159 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004160
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004161 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4162 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004163 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004164 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004165 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4166 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4167 // to get a consistent AST.
4168 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004169 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4170 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004171 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004172 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004173 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004174 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4175 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004176 return LHSTy;
4177 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004178
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004179 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4180 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4181 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004182 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4183 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004184
4185 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4186 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4187 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004188 QualType destPointee
4189 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004190 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004191 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4192 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4193 // Promote to void*.
4194 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004195 return destType;
4196 }
4197 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004198 QualType destPointee
4199 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004200 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004201 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004202 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004203 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004204 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004205 return destType;
4206 }
4207
4208 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4209 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4210 return LHSTy;
4211 }
4212 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4213 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4214 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4215 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4216 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4217 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4218 // to get a consistent AST.
4219 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004220 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4221 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004222 return incompatTy;
4223 }
4224 // The pointer types are compatible.
4225 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4226 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4227 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4228 // type.
4229 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4230 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004231 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4232 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004233 return LHSTy;
4234 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004235
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004236 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4237 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4238 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4239 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004240 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004241 return RHSTy;
4242 }
4243 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4244 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4245 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004246 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004247 return LHSTy;
4248 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004249
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004250 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004251 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4252 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004253 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004254}
4255
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004256/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4257/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4258QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4259 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4260 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4261 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004262
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004263 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4264 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4265 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4266 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4267 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4268 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4269 return LHSTy;
4270 }
4271 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4272 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4273 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4274 return RHSTy;
4275 }
4276 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4277 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4278 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4279 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4280 return LHSTy;
4281 }
4282 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4283 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4284 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4285 return RHSTy;
4286 }
4287 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4288 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4289 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4290 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4291 return LHSTy;
4292 }
4293 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4294 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4295 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4296 return RHSTy;
4297 }
4298 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4299 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004300
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004301 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4302 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4303 return LHSTy;
4304 }
4305 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4306 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4307 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004308
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004309 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4310 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4311 // type. This allows
4312 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4313 // where B is a subclass of A.
4314 //
4315 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4316 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4317 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4318 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004319
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004320 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4321 // It could return the composite type.
4322 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4323 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4324 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4325 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4326 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4327 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4328 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4329 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4330 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4331 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4332 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4333 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4334 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4335 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004336 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004337 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4338 ;
4339 else {
4340 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4341 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4342 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4343 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4344 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4345 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4346 return incompatTy;
4347 }
4348 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4349 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4350 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4351 return compositeType;
4352 }
4353 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4354 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4355 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4356 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4357 QualType destPointee
4358 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4359 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4360 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4361 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4362 // Promote to void*.
4363 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4364 return destType;
4365 }
4366 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4367 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4368 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4369 QualType destPointee
4370 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4371 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4372 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4373 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4374 // Promote to void*.
4375 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4376 return destType;
4377 }
4378 return QualType();
4379}
4380
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004381/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004382/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004383Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4384 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4385 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4386 ExprArg RHS) {
4387 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4388 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004389
4390 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4391 // was the condition.
4392 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4393 if (isLHSNull)
4394 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004395
4396 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004397 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004398 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004399 return ExprError();
4400
4401 Cond.release();
4402 LHS.release();
4403 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004404 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004405 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004406 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004407}
4408
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004409// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004410// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004411// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4412// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4413// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004414Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004415Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004416 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004417
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004418 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4419 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4420 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4421 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4422 return Compatible;
4423 }
4424
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004425 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004426 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4427 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004428
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004429 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004430 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4431 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004432
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004433 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004434
4435 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4436 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4437 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004438 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004439 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004440 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004441
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004442 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4443 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004444 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004445 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004446 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004447 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004448
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004449 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004450 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4451 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004452 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004453
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004454 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004455 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004456 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004457
4458 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004459 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4460 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004461 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004462 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004463 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004464 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4465 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4466 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4467 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4468 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4469 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004470 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004471 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004472 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004473 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004474
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004475 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004476 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004477 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004478 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004479
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004480 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4481 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4482 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4483 // warning can be disabled.
4484 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4485 return ConvTy;
4486 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4487 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004488
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004489 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4490 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4491 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4492 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4493 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4494 do {
4495 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4496 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004497
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004498 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4499 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4500 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004501
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004502 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004503 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004504 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004505
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004506 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004507 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004508 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004509 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004510}
4511
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004512/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4513/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4514/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4515// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004516Sema::AssignConvertType
4517Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004518 QualType rhsType) {
4519 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004520
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004521 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004522 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4523 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004524
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004525 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4526 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4527 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004528
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004529 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004530
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004531 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004532 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004533 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004534
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004535 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4536 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4537 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4538 }
4539 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004540 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004541 return ConvTy;
4542}
4543
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004544/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4545/// for assignment compatibility.
4546Sema::AssignConvertType
4547Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004548 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4549 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004550 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4551 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004552 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004553 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004554 }
4555 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4556 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004557 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4558 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004559 return IncompatiblePointer;
4560 return Compatible;
4561 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004562 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004563 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004564 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004565 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4566 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4567 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4568 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4569 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4570 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004571
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004572 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4573 return Compatible;
4574 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4575 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004576 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004577}
4578
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004579/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4580/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004581/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4582///
4583/// int a, *pint;
4584/// short *pshort;
4585/// struct foo *pfoo;
4586///
4587/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4588/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4589/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4590/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4591///
4592/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004593/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004594///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004595Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004596Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004597 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4598 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004599 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4600 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004601
4602 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004603 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004604
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004605 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4606 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4607 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4608 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4609 return Compatible;
4610 }
4611
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004612 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4613 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4614 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4615 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4616 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4617 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4618 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004619 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004620 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004621 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004622 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004623 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004624 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4625 // to the same ExtVector type.
4626 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4627 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4628 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
4629 if (!rhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
4630 return Compatible;
4631 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004632
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004633 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004634 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004635 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004636 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004637 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4638 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004639 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004640 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004641 }
4642 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004643 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004644
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004645 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4646 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004647 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004648
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004649 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004650 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004651 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004652
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004653 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004654 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004655
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004656 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004657 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004658 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4659 return Compatible;
4660 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004661 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004662 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4663 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004664 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004665
4666 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004667 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004668 return Compatible;
4669 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004670 return Incompatible;
4671 }
4672
4673 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4674 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004675 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004676
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004677 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004678 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004679 return Compatible;
4680
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004681 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4682 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004683
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004684 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004685 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004686 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004687 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004688 return Incompatible;
4689 }
4690
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004691 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4692 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4693 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004694
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004695 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004696 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004697 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4698 return Compatible;
4699 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004700 }
4701 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004702 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004703 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004704 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004705 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4706 return Compatible;
4707 }
4708 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4709 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4710 return Compatible;
4711 return Incompatible;
4712 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004713 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004714 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004715 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4716 return Compatible;
4717
4718 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004719 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004720
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004721 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004722 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004723
4724 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004725 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004726 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004727 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004728 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004729 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4730 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4731 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4732 return Compatible;
4733
4734 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4735 return PointerToInt;
4736
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004737 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004738 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004739 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4740 return Compatible;
4741 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004742 }
4743 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004744 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004745 return Compatible;
4746 return Incompatible;
4747 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004748
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004749 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004750 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004751 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004752 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004753 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004754}
4755
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004756/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4757/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004758static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004759 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4760 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4761 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004762 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004763 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004764 SourceLocation());
4765 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4766 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4767
4768 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4769 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004770 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004771 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004772 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004773}
4774
4775Sema::AssignConvertType
4776Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4777 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4778
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004779 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004780 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4781 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004782 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004783 return Incompatible;
4784
4785 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4786 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4787 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4788 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004789 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4790 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004791 it != itend; ++it) {
4792 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4793 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4794 // 1) void pointer
4795 // 2) null pointer constant
4796 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004797 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004798 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004799 InitField = *it;
4800 break;
4801 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004802
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004803 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004804 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004805 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004806 InitField = *it;
4807 break;
4808 }
4809 }
4810
4811 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4812 == Compatible) {
4813 InitField = *it;
4814 break;
4815 }
4816 }
4817
4818 if (!InitField)
4819 return Incompatible;
4820
4821 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4822 return Compatible;
4823}
4824
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004825Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004826Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004827 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4828 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4829 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4830 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4831 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004832 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004833 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004834 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004835 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004836 }
4837
4838 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4839 // structures.
4840 }
4841
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004842 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4843 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004844 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4845 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004846 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004847 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004848 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004849 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004850 return Compatible;
4851 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004852
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004853 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004854 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004855 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004856 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004857 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004858 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004859 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004860 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004861
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004862 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4863 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004864
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004865 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4866 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004867 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4868 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4869 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4870 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004871 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004872 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4873 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004874 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004875}
4876
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004877QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004878 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004879 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004880 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004881 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00004882}
4883
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004884QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004885 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004886 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004887 QualType lhsType =
4888 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4889 QualType rhsType =
4890 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004891
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004892 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004893 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004894 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004895
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004896 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4897 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004898 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4899 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004900 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4901 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004902 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004903 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004904 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4905 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4906 return lhsType;
4907 }
4908
4909 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4910 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004911 }
4912 }
4913 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004914
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004915 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
4916 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
4917 bool swapped = false;
4918 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4919 swapped = true;
4920 std::swap(rex, lex);
4921 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
4922 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004923
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004924 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004925 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004926 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004927 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004928 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004929 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004930 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4931 return lhsType;
4932 }
4933 }
4934 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
4935 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
4936 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004937 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004938 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4939 return lhsType;
4940 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004941 }
4942 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004943
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004944 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004945 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004946 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004947 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004948 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00004949}
4950
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004951QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
4952 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00004953 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004954 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004955
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004956 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004957
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004958 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
4959 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4960 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004961
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004962 // Check for division by zero.
4963 if (isDiv &&
4964 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004965 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004966 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004967
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004968 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00004969}
4970
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004971QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004972 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00004973 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
4974 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4975 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4976 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4977 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004978
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004979 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004980
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004981 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4982 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004983
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004984 // Check for remainder by zero.
4985 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004986 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
4987 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004988
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004989 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00004990}
4991
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004992QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004993 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00004994 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
4995 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4996 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
4997 return compType;
4998 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00004999
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005000 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005001
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005002 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005003 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5004 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5005 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005006 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005007 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005008
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005009 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5010 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005011 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005012 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5013
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005014 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005015
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005016 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005017 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005018
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005019 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5020 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005021 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5022 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005023 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005024 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005025 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005026
5027 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5028 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5029 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005030 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005031 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5032 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5033 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5034 return QualType();
5035 }
5036
5037 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5038 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5039 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005040 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005041 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005042 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005043 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005044 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5045 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005046 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5047 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005048 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005049 return QualType();
5050 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005051 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005052 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005053 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5054 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5055 return QualType();
5056 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005057
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005058 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005059 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5060 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5061 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5062 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5063 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005064 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005065 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5066 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005067 return PExp->getType();
5068 }
5069 }
5070
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005071 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005072}
5073
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005074// C99 6.5.6
5075QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005076 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5077 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5078 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5079 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5080 return compType;
5081 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005082
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005083 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005084
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005085 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005086
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005087 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005088 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5089 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005090 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005091 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005092 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005093
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005094 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005095 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005096 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005097
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005098 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005099
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005100 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5101 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5102 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5103 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5104 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5105 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5106 return QualType();
5107 }
5108
5109 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5110 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5111 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5112 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5113 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005114 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005115 return QualType();
5116 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005117
5118 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5119 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5120 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005121 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005122 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005123 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005124 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005125 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005126
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005127 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005128 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005129 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5130 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5131 return QualType();
5132 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005133
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005134 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005135 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5136 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5137 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5138 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5139 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5140 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005141 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005142 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5143
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005144 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005145 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005146 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005147
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005148 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005149 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005150 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005151
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005152 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5153 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5154 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5155 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5156 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5157 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5158 return QualType();
5159 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005160
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005161 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5162 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5163 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5164 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005165 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005166 return QualType();
5167 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005168
5169 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5170 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5171 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5172 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5173 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005174 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5175 << rex->getSourceRange()
5176 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005177 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005178
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005179 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5180 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5181 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5182 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5183 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5184 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5185 return QualType();
5186 }
5187 } else {
5188 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5189 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5190 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5191 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5192 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5193 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5194 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5195 return QualType();
5196 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005197 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005198
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005199 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5200 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5201 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5202 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5203 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005204 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005205 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005206
5207 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005208 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5209 }
5210 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005211
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005212 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005213}
5214
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005215// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005216QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005217 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005218 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5219 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005220 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005221
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005222 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5223 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5224 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5225
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005226 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5227 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005228 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5229 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5230 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5231 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5232 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005233 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005234 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005235 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005236
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005237 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005238
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005239 // Sanity-check shift operands
5240 llvm::APSInt Right;
5241 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005242 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5243 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005244 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005245 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5246 else {
5247 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5248 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5249 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5250 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5251 }
5252 }
5253
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005254 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005255 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005256}
5257
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005258// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005259QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005260 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5261 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5262
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005263 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005264 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005265 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005266
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005267 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5268 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005269
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005270 if (!lType->isFloatingType()
5271 && !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005272 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5273 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5274 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005275 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenekde9e9682009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005276 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005277 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5278 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5279 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005280 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenek9ffbe412009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005281 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005282 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl())) {
5283 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5284 << 0 // self-
5285 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::EQ
5286 || Opc == BinaryOperator::LE
5287 || Opc == BinaryOperator::GE));
5288 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5289 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5290 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5291 // what is it always going to eval to?
5292 char always_evals_to;
5293 switch(Opc) {
5294 case BinaryOperator::EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
5295 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5296 break;
5297 case BinaryOperator::NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
5298 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5299 break;
5300 default:
5301 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5302 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5303 break;
5304 }
5305 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5306 << 1 // array
5307 << always_evals_to);
5308 }
5309 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005310
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005311 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5312 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5313 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5314 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005315
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005316 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5317 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005318 Expr *literalString = 0;
5319 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005320 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005321 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005322 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005323 literalString = lex;
5324 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005325 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5326 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005327 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005328 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005329 literalString = rex;
5330 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5331 }
5332
5333 if (literalString) {
5334 std::string resultComparison;
5335 switch (Opc) {
5336 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5337 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5338 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5339 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5340 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5341 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5342 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5343 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005344
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005345 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5346 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5347 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005348 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005349 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005350 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005351
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005352 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5353 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5354 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5355 else {
5356 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5357 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5358 }
5359
5360 lType = lex->getType();
5361 rType = rex->getType();
5362
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005363 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005364 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005365
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005366 if (isRelational) {
5367 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005368 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005369 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005370 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005371 if (lType->isFloatingType() && rType->isFloatingType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005372 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005373
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005374 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005375 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005376 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005377
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005378 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005379 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005380 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005381 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005382
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005383 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5384 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005385 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005386 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005387 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005388 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005389 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005390
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005392 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5393 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005394 if (!isRelational &&
5395 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5396 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5397 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005398 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5399 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005400 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5401 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005402 Diag(Loc,
5403 isSFINAEContext()?
5404 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5405 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005406 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005407
5408 if (isSFINAEContext())
5409 return QualType();
5410
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005411 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5412 return ResultTy;
5413 }
5414 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005415 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5416 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5417 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5418 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5419 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5420 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005421 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005422 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005423 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005424 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005425 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005426 if (T.isNull()) {
5427 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5428 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5429 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005430 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005431 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005432 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005433 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005434 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005435 }
5436
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005437 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5438 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005439 return ResultTy;
5440 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005441 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5442 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5443 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5444 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5445 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5446 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5447 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5448 }
5449 } else if (!isRelational &&
5450 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5451 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5452 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5453 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5454 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5455 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5456 }
5457 } else {
5458 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005459 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005460 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005461 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005462 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005463 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005464 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005465 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005466
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005467 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005468 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005469 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005470 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005471 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5472 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005473 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005474 return ResultTy;
5475 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005476 if (LHSIsNull &&
5477 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5478 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005479 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005480 return ResultTy;
5481 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005482
5483 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005484 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005485 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5486 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005487 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5488 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5489 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5490 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5491 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5492 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5493 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5494 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005495 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005496 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005497 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005498 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005499 if (T.isNull()) {
5500 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005501 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005502 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005503 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005504 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005505 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005506 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005507 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005508 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005509
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005510 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5511 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005512 return ResultTy;
5513 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005514
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005515 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005516 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5517 return ResultTy;
5518 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005519
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005520 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005521 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005522 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5523 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005524
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005525 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005526 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005527 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005528 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005529 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005530 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005531 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005532 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005533 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005534 if (!isRelational
5535 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5536 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005537 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005538 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005539 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005540 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005541 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5542 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5543 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005544 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005545 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005546 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005547 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005548
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005549 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005550 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005551 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5552 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005553 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005554 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005555 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005556 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005557
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005558 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5559 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005560 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005561 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005562 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005563 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005564 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005565 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005566 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005567 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005568 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5569 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005570 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005571 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005572 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005573 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005574 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5575 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005576 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005577 bool isError = false;
5578 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5579 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5580 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005581 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005582 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005583 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005584 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5585 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5586 isError = true;
5587 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005588 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005589
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005590 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005591 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005592 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005593 if (isError)
5594 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005595 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005596
5597 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5598 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005599 else
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005600 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005601 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005602 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005603
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005604 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005605 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5606 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005607 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005608 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005609 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005610 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5611 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005612 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005613 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005614 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005615 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005616}
5617
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005618/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005619/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005620/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5621/// types.
5622QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005623 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005624 bool isRelational) {
5625 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5626 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005627 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005628 if (vType.isNull())
5629 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005630
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005631 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5632 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005633
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005634 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5635 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5636 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
5637 if (!lType->isFloatingType()) {
5638 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5639 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5640 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005641 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5642 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5643 << 0 // self-
5644 << 2 // "a constant"
5645 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005646 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005647
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005648 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
5649 if (!isRelational && lType->isFloatingType()) {
5650 assert (rType->isFloatingType());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005651 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005652 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005653
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005654 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5655 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5656 // elements for floating point vectors.
5657 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5658 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005659
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005660 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005661 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005662 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005663 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005664 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005665 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5666
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005667 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005668 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005669 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5670}
5671
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005672inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005673 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff94a5aca2007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005674 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005675 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005676
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005677 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005678
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005679 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005680 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005681 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005682}
5683
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005684inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005685 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005686 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5687 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5688 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005689
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005690 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5691 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005692
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005693 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005694 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005695
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005696 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5697 // non-overloadable operands.
5698
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005699 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5700 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005701 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5702 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5703 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005704 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005705
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005706 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5707 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5708 // The result is a bool.
5709 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005710}
5711
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005712/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5713/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5714/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5715///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005716static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005717 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5718 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5719 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5720 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005721 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005722 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5723 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5724 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5725 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005726 }
5727 }
5728 return false;
5729}
5730
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005731/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5732/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5733static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005734 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005735 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005736 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005737 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5738 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005739 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5740 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005741
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005742 unsigned Diag = 0;
5743 bool NeedType = false;
5744 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005745 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005746 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005747 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5748 NeedType = true;
5749 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005750 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005751 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5752 NeedType = true;
5753 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005754 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005755 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5756 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005757 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5758 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005759 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005760 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5761 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005762 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5763 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005764 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5765 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005766 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005767 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005768 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005769 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005770 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5771 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005772 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005773 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5774 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005775 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5776 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5777 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005778 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5779 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5780 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005781 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5782 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5783 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005784 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005785
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005786 SourceRange Assign;
5787 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5788 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005789 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005790 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005791 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005792 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005793 return true;
5794}
5795
5796
5797
5798// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005799QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5800 SourceLocation Loc,
5801 QualType CompoundType) {
5802 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5803 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005804 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005805
5806 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5807 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005808 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005809 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005810 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005811 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005812 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
5813 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
5814 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
5815 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
5816 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
5817 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
5818 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
5819 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
5820 }
5821 }
5822
5823 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005824 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5825 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5826 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005827 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005828 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005829 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005830 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005831
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005832 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5833 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5834 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005835 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005836 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5837 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5838 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5839 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5840 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005841 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005842 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005843 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5844 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5845 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005846 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5847 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005848 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5849 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5850 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005851 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005852 }
5853 } else {
5854 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005855 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005856 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005857
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005858 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005859 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005860 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005861
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005862 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5863 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005864 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005865 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5866 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005867 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005868 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005869 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005870}
5871
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005872// C99 6.5.17
5873QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005874 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005875 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5876 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5877 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005878
5879 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5880 // incomplete in C++).
5881
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005882 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00005883}
5884
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005885/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5886/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005887QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005888 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005889 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5890 return Context.DependentTy;
5891
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005892 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5893 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00005894
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005895 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5896 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5897 if (!isInc) {
5898 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5899 return QualType();
5900 }
5901 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5902 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5903 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005904 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005905 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5906 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005907
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005908 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005909 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005910 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5911 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5912 << Op->getSourceRange();
5913 return QualType();
5914 }
5915
5916 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005917 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005918 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005919 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5920 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5921 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5922 return QualType();
5923 }
5924
5925 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005926 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005927 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005928 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005929 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005930 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005931 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005932 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005933 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005934 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5935 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5936 return QualType();
5937 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00005938 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005939 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
5940 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005941 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005942 } else {
5943 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00005944 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005945 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00005946 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005947 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00005948 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005949 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00005950 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005951 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
5952 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
5953 // operand.
5954 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5955 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005956}
5957
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005958/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005959/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005960/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
5961/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
5962/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
5963/// - &(x) => x
5964/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
5965/// - &s.xx => s
5966/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
5967/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
5968/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
5969/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005970static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005971 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005972 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005973 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005974 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005975 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
5976 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
5977 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005978 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005979 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005980 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005981 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005982 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00005983 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
5984 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005985 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
5986 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
5987 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
5988 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
5989 }
5990 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005991 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005992 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
5993 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005994
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005995 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005996 case UnaryOperator::Real:
5997 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
5998 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
5999 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6000 default:
6001 return 0;
6002 }
6003 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006004 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006005 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006006 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006007 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6008 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006009 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006010 default:
6011 return 0;
6012 }
6013}
6014
6015/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006016/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006017/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006018/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006019/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006020/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006021/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006022QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006023 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6024 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6025
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006026 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6027 return Context.DependentTy;
6028
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006029 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6030 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6031 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6032 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6033 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6034 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6035 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6036 }
6037 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6038 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6039 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006040 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006041 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006042
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006043 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6044 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6045 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6046 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6047 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6048 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6049 // branch of the if, below.
6050 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6051 << dcl;
6052 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6053
6054 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6055 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6056 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6057 .getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006058 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
6059 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6060 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6061 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6062 if (isSFINAEContext())
6063 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian6fdb1392010-06-17 21:45:48 +00006064 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
6065 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006066 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006067 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006068 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006069 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006070 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006071 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6072 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006073 return QualType();
6074 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006075 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006076 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6077 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6078 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006079 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006080 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006081 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006082 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006083 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006084 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006085 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6086 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6087 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6088 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6089 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006090 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6091 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006092 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6093 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006094 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6095 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006096 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006097 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006098 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6099 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006100 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006101 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6102 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006103 return QualType();
6104 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006105 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006106 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006107 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006108 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006109 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6110 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006111 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006112 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006113 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6114 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006115 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006116 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6117 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6118 return QualType();
6119 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006120
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006121 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6122 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006123 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006124 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006125 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006126 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006127 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006128 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6129 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006130 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6131 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6132 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006133 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006134 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006135
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006136 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6137 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6138 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6139 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6140 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6141 }
6142
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006143 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006144 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006145}
6146
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006147QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006148 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6149 return Context.DependentTy;
6150
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006151 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
6152 QualType Ty = Op->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006153
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006154 // Note that per both C89 and C99, this is always legal, even if ptype is an
6155 // incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about dereferencing
6156 // a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a warning is
6157 // unlikely to catch any mistakes.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006158 if (const PointerType *PT = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006159 return PT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006160
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006161 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Fariborz Jahanianf15d4b62009-09-03 00:43:07 +00006162 return OPT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006163
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006164 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006165 << Ty << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006166 return QualType();
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006167}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006168
6169static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6170 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6171 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6172 switch (Kind) {
6173 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006174 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6175 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006176 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6177 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6178 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6179 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6180 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6181 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6182 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6183 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6184 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6185 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6186 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6187 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6188 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6189 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6190 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6191 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6192 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6193 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6194 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6195 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6196 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6197 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6198 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6199 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6200 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6201 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6202 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6203 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6204 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6205 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6206 }
6207 return Opc;
6208}
6209
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006210static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6211 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6212 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6213 switch (Kind) {
6214 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6215 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6216 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6217 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6218 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6219 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6220 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6221 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6222 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006223 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6224 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006225 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006226 }
6227 return Opc;
6228}
6229
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006230/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6231/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6232/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006233Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6234 unsigned Op,
6235 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006236 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006237 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006238 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6239 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6240 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006241
6242 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006243 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6244 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6245 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006246 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6247 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6248 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6249 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6250 break;
6251 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006252 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006253 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6254 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006255 break;
6256 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6257 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6258 break;
6259 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6260 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6261 break;
6262 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6263 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6264 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006265 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006266 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6267 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6268 break;
6269 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6270 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6271 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6272 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006273 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006274 break;
6275 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6276 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006277 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006278 break;
6279 case BinaryOperator::And:
6280 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6281 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6282 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6283 break;
6284 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6285 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6286 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6287 break;
6288 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6289 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006290 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6291 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006292 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6293 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6294 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006295 break;
6296 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006297 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6298 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6299 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6300 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006301 break;
6302 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006303 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6304 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6305 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006306 break;
6307 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006308 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6309 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6310 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006311 break;
6312 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6313 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006314 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6315 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6316 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6317 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006318 break;
6319 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6320 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6321 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006322 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6323 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6324 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6325 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006326 break;
6327 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6328 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6329 break;
6330 }
6331 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006332 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006333 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006334 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6335 else
6336 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006337 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6338 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006339}
6340
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006341/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6342/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006343static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6344 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006345 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6346 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6347 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006348 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006349 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6350
6351 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6352 return;
6353
6354 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6355 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6356 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006357 return;
6358 }
6359
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006360 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6361 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006362 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006363
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006364 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006365 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006366
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006367 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6368 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6369 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6370 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006371 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006372 return;
6373 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006374
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006375 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006376 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6377 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006378}
6379
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006380/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6381/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6382/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6383/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006384static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6385 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006386 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6387 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6388 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6389 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006390 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006391 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006392 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6393
6394 // Subs are not binary operators.
6395 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6396 return;
6397
6398 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6399 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006400 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6401 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006402 return;
6403
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006404 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006405 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006406 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006407 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6408 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006409 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006410 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006411 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6412 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6413 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6414 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006415 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006416 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006417 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006418 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6419 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006420 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006421 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006422 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6423 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6424 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6425 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006426}
6427
6428/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6429/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6430/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6431static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6432 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006433 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006434 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6435}
6436
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006437// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006438Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6439 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6440 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006441 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006442 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006443
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006444 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6445 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006446
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006447 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6448 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6449
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006450 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6451}
6452
6453Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6454 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6455 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006456 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006457 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006458 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6459 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6460 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6461 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6462 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006463 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006464 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006465 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6466 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6467 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006468
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006469 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6470 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006471 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006472 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006473
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006474 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006475 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006476}
6477
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006478Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006479 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006480 ExprArg InputArg) {
6481 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006482
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006483 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006484 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006485 QualType resultType;
6486 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006487 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6488 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6489 break;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006490
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006491 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6492 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006493 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6494 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006495 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006496 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006497 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6498 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6499 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006500 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006501 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006502 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006503 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006504 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006505 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006506 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006507 break;
6508 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6509 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006510 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6511 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006512 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6513 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006514 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6515 break;
6516 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6517 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6518 break;
6519 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6520 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6521 resultType->isPointerType())
6522 break;
6523
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006524 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6525 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006526 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006527 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6528 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006529 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6530 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006531 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6532 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6533 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006534 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006535 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006536 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006537 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6538 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006539 break;
6540 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006541 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006542 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006543 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006544 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6545 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006546 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006547 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6548 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006549 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006550 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6551 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006552 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006553 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006554 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006555 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006556 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006557 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006558 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006559 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006560 }
6561 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006562 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006563
6564 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006565 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006566}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006567
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006568Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6569 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6570 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006571 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006572 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6573 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006574 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6575 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6576 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6577 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006578 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006579 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006580 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6581 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6582 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006583
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006584 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6585 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006586
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006587 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6588}
6589
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006590// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6591Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6592 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6593 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6594}
6595
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006596/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006597Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6598 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6599 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006600 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006601 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006602
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006603 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6604 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006605 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006606 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006607
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006608 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006609 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6610 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006611}
6612
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006613Sema::OwningExprResult
6614Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6615 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6616 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006617 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6618 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6619
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006620 bool isFileScope
6621 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006622 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006623 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006624
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006625 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6626 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6627 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006628
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006629 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6630 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6631 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006632
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006633 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6634 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6635 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6636 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6637 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006638
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006639 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006640 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006641 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006642
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006643 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6644 // expressions are not lvalues.
6645
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006646 substmt.release();
6647 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006648}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006649
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006650Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6651 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006652 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6653 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006654 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6655 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006656 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006657 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006658
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006659 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6660 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6661 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006662 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006663 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6664 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6665
6666 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6667 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6668 if (!Dependent
6669 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6670 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6671 << TypeRange))
6672 return ExprError();
6673
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006674 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6675 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006676 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6677 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006678 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006679 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6680 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006681
6682 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6683 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6684 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6685 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6686 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6687 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6688 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6689 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6690 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6691 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6692 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6693 if(!AT)
6694 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6695 << CurrentType);
6696 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6697 } else
6698 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6699
6700 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6701 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6702 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6703 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6704 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6705 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6706 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6707 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6708
6709 // Record this array index.
6710 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6711 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6712 continue;
6713 }
6714
6715 // Offset of a field.
6716 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6717 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6718 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6719 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6720 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6721 continue;
6722 }
6723
6724 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6725 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6726 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6727 return ExprError();
6728
6729 // Look for the designated field.
6730 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6731 if (!RC)
6732 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6733 << CurrentType);
6734 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6735
6736 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6737 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6738 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6739 // (clause 9).
6740 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6741 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6742 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6743 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6744 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6745 << CurrentType))
6746 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6747 }
6748
6749 // Look for the field.
6750 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6751 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6752 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6753 if (!MemberDecl)
6754 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6755 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6756 OC.LocEnd));
6757
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006758 // C99 7.17p3:
6759 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6760 //
6761 // We diagnose this as an error.
6762 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6763 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6764 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6765 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6766 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6767 return ExprError();
6768 }
6769
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006770 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6771 // the base class indirections.
6772 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6773 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
6774 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType,
6775 Context.getTypeDeclType(MemberDecl->getParent()),
6776 Paths)) {
6777 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6778 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6779 B != BEnd; ++B)
6780 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6781 }
6782
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006783 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006784 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006785 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6786 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6787 unsigned n = Path.size();
6788 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6789 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6790 } else {
6791 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6792 }
6793 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6794 }
6795
6796 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6797 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6798 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6799}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006800
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006801Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6802 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6803 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6804 TypeTy *argty,
6805 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6806 unsigned NumComponents,
6807 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6808
6809 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6810 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6811 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6812 return ExprError();
6813
6814 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6815 if (!ArgTInfo)
6816 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6817
6818 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6819 RPLoc);
6820 }
6821
6822 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
6823 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
6824
6825 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6826
6827 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6828 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6829 // a struct/union/class.
6830 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
6831 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
6832
6833 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6834 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
6835
6836 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6837 // the offsetof designators.
6838 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6839 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
6840 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
6841 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
6842
6843 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6844 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
6845 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6846 // a system header!
6847 if (NumComponents != 1)
6848 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6849 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
6850
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006851 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedman8469bc72009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006852 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006853
John McCall9eff4e62009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006854 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6855 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6856 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006857
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006858 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6859 // leaks like a sieve.
6860 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6861 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6862 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6863 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6864 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6865 if (!AT) {
6866 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006867 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006868 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006869 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006870
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006871 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006872
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006873 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6874 // expression.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006875 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006876
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006877 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6878 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006879 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006880 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006881 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006882 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006883 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6884
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006885 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6886 OC.LocEnd);
6887 continue;
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006888 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006889
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006890 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006891 if (!RC) {
6892 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006893 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006894 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006895 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006896
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006897 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6898 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006899 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006900 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6901 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6902 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006903 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6904 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006905 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006906 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006907
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006908 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6909 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006910
John McCall67c00872009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006911 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006912 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006913 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregore40876a2009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006914 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006915 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
6916
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006917 // C99 7.17p3:
6918 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6919 //
6920 // We diagnose this as an error.
6921 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6922 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6923 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6924 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6925 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6926 return ExprError();
6927 }
6928
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006929 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6930 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006931 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006932 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006933 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006934 } else {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006935 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6936 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006937 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6938 // doesn't matter here.
6939 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006940 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006941 }
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006942 }
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006943 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006944
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006945 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6946 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006947}
6948
6949
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006950Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6951 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6952 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006953 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6954 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6955 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006956
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006957 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006958
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00006959 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6960 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
6961 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6962 return ExprError();
6963 }
6964
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006965 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
6966 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006967}
6968
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006969Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6970 ExprArg cond,
6971 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
6972 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6973 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
6974 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
6975 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006976
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006977 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
6978
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006979 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006980 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00006981 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006982 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006983 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006984 } else {
6985 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
6986 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
6987 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
6988 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006989 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
6990 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
6991 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006992
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006993 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
6994 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006995 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
6996 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006997 }
6998
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006999 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
7000 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007001 resType, RPLoc,
7002 resType->isDependentType(),
7003 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007004}
7005
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007006//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7007// Clang Extensions.
7008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7009
7010/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007011void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007012 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7013 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7014 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
7015 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007016}
7017
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007018void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007019 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007020 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007021
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007022 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007023 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007024 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007025
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007026 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007027 QualType RetTy;
7028 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007029 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007030 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007031 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007032 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7033 } else {
7034 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007035 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007036 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007037
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007038 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007039
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007040 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7041 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7042 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007043 return;
7044 }
7045
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007046 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7047 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7048 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7049 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7050 return;
7051 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007052
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007053 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007054 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7055 // ^ * { ... }
7056 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007057 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7058 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007059
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007060 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007061 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007062 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7063 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7064 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7065 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007066 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7067 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7068 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7069 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7070 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007071 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007072 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007073
7074 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7075 // ^ fntype { ... }
7076 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7077 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7078 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7079 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7080 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7081 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7082 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007083 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007084 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007085 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007086
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007087 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7088 if (!Params.empty())
7089 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007090
7091 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007092 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007093
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007094 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007095 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7096 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7097 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7098 }
7099
7100 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7101 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007102 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007103 return;
7104
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007105 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7106 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7107
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007108 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007109 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7110 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7111
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007112 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007113 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7114 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7115 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7116
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007117 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007118 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007119 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007120}
7121
7122/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7123/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7124void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007125 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007126 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007127 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007128 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007129}
7130
7131/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7132/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007133Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7134 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007135 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7136 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7137 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007138
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007139 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007140
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007141 PopDeclContext();
7142
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007143 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007144 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7145 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007146
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007147 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007148 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007149
7150 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7151 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7152 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7153
7154 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7155 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7156
7157 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7158 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7159 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7160 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7161
7162 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7163 // preserve its sugar structure.
7164 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7165 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7166 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7167
7168 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7169 } else {
7170 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7171 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7172 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7173 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7174 FPT->isVariadic(),
7175 /*quals*/ 0,
7176 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7177 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7178 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7179 FPT->exception_begin(),
7180 Ext);
7181 }
7182
7183 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7184 } else {
7185 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7186 false, false, 0, 0,
7187 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7188 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007189
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007190 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007191 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7192 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007193 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007194
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007195 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007196 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007197 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007198
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007199 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007200
7201 bool Good = true;
7202 // Check goto/label use.
7203 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7204 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7205 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7206
7207 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7208 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7209 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7210 continue;
7211
7212 // Emit error.
7213 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7214 Good = false;
7215 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007216 if (!Good) {
7217 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007218 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007219 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007220
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007221 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007222 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7223 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7224 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007225
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007226 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7227 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007228 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007229 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007230}
7231
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007232Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7233 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7234 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007235 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007236 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7237 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007238
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007239 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007240
7241 // Get the va_list type
7242 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007243 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7244 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7245 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7246 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007247 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007248 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7249 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7250 } else {
7251 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7252 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007253 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007254 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007255 return ExprError();
7256 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007257
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007258 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7259 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007260 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7261 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007262 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007263 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007264
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007265 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007266 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007267
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007268 expr.release();
7269 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7270 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007271}
7272
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007273Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007274 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7275 // pointers on the target.
7276 QualType Ty;
7277 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7278 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7279 else
7280 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7281
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007282 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007283}
7284
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007285static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007286 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007287 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7288 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007289
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007290 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7291 if (!PT)
7292 return;
7293
7294 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7295 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7296 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7297 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7298 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7299 return;
7300 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007301
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007302 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7303 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7304 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7305 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007306
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007307 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007308}
7309
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007310bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7311 SourceLocation Loc,
7312 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007313 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7314 bool *Complained) {
7315 if (Complained)
7316 *Complained = false;
7317
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007318 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7319 bool isInvalid = false;
7320 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007321 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007322
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007323 switch (ConvTy) {
7324 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7325 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007326 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007327 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7328 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007329 case IntToPointer:
7330 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7331 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007332 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007333 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007334 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7335 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007336 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7337 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7338 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007339 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7340 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7341 break;
7342 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007343 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7344 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7345 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7346 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7347 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7348 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7349 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7350 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7351 // C++ semantics.
7352 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7353 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7354 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007355 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7356 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007357 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007358 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007359 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007360 case IntToBlockPointer:
7361 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7362 break;
7363 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007364 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007365 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007366 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007367 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007368 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7369 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7370 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007371 case IncompatibleVectors:
7372 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7373 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007374 case Incompatible:
7375 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7376 isInvalid = true;
7377 break;
7378 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007379
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007380 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7381 switch (Action) {
7382 case AA_Assigning:
7383 case AA_Initializing:
7384 // The destination type comes first.
7385 FirstType = DstType;
7386 SecondType = SrcType;
7387 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007388
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007389 case AA_Returning:
7390 case AA_Passing:
7391 case AA_Converting:
7392 case AA_Sending:
7393 case AA_Casting:
7394 // The source type comes first.
7395 FirstType = SrcType;
7396 SecondType = DstType;
7397 break;
7398 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007399
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007400 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007401 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007402 if (Complained)
7403 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007404 return isInvalid;
7405}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007406
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007407bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007408 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7409 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7410 if (Result)
7411 *Result = ICEResult;
7412 return false;
7413 }
7414
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007415 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7416
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007417 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007418 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7419 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7420
7421 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7422 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7423 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7424 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7425 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7426 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7427 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007428
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007429 return true;
7430 }
7431
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007432 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7433 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007434
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007435 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7436 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7437 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007438
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007439 if (Result)
7440 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7441 return false;
7442}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007443
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007444void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007445Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007446 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7447 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007448}
7449
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007450void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007451Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7452 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7453 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7454 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007455
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007456 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7457 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7458 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7459 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7460 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007461 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007462 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7463 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7464 I != IEnd; ++I)
7465 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7466 }
7467
7468 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7469 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7470 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7471 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7472 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7473 I != IEnd; ++I)
7474 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7475 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007476 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007477
7478 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7479 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7480 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7481 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007482 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007483 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7484 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7485 ExprTemporaries.end());
7486
7487 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7488 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007489}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007490
7491/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7492///
7493/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7494/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7495/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7496/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7497///
7498/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7499///
7500/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7501void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7502 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007503
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007504 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007505 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007506
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007507 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7508 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7509 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7510 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007511 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007512 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007513 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007514 return;
7515 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007516
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007517 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7518 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007519
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007520 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7521 // an instantiation.
7522 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7523 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007524
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007525 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007526 case Unevaluated:
7527 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7528 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007529
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007530 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7531 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7532 // "used"; handle this below.
7533 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007534
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007535 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7536 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7537 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7538 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007539 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007540 return;
7541 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007542
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007543 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007544 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007545 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007546 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007547 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007548 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007549 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007550 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007551 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007552 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7553 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007554
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007555 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007556 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007557 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007558 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007559 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7560 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007561 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7562 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7563 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007564 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007565 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007566 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7567 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007568 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007569 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007570 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007571 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007572 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007573 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7574 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7575 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7576 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7577 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007578 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007579 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007580 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007581 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007582 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7583 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7584 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007585 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007586 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007587 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7588 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007589
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007590 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7591 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7592 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7593 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7594 Loc));
7595 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007596 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007597 Loc));
7598 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007599 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007600
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007601 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007602 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007603
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007604 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007605 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007606
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007607 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007608 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007609 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007610 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7611 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7612 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7613 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7614 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7615 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7616 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7617 }
7618 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007619
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007620 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007621
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007622 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007623 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007624 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007625}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007626
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007627namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007628 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007629 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007630 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007631 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7632 Sema &S;
7633 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007634
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007635 public:
7636 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007637
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007638 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007639
7640 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7641 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007642 };
7643}
7644
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007645bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7646 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007647 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7648 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7649 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007650
7651 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007652}
7653
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007654bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007655 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7656 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7657 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007658 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7659 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007660 }
7661
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007662 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007663}
7664
7665void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7666 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007667 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007668}
7669
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007670/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7671/// of the program being compiled.
7672///
7673/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007674/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007675/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7676/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7677/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7678/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007679/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007680/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007681///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007682/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7683/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7684/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7685/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007686bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007687 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7688 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7689 case Unevaluated:
7690 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7691 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007692
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007693 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7694 Diag(Loc, PD);
7695 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007696
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007697 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7698 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7699 break;
7700 }
7701
7702 return false;
7703}
7704
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007705bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7706 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7707 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7708 return false;
7709
7710 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7711 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7712 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7713 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007714
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007715 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007716 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007717 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7718 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007719 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007720 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7721 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7722 return true;
7723
7724 return false;
7725}
7726
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007727// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7728// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7729void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7730 SourceLocation Loc;
7731
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007732 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7733
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007734 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7735 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7736 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7737 return;
7738
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007739 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7740 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7741 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7742 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7743
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007744 // self = [<foo> init...]
7745 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7746 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7747 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7748
7749 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7750 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7751 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7752 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7753 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007754
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007755 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7756 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7757 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7758 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7759 return;
7760
7761 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7762 } else {
7763 // Not an assignment.
7764 return;
7765 }
7766
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007767 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007768 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007769
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007770 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007771 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007772 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007773 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7774 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7775 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007776}
7777
7778bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7779 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7780
7781 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007782 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007783
7784 QualType T = E->getType();
7785
7786 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7787 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7788 return true;
7789 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7790 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7791 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7792 return true;
7793 }
7794 }
7795
7796 return false;
7797}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007798
7799Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7800 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007801 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7802 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007803 return ExprError();
7804
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007805 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc)) {
7806 Sub->Destroy(Context);
7807 return ExprError();
7808 }
7809
7810 return Owned(Sub);
7811}